440aa04ad87f6d5b5035a3b9e4791bcdfbf92730
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a server.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Server Configuration
1998 @chapter Server Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2407 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2408 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2409
2410 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2411 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX.
2412
2413 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2414 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2415 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2416
2417 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2418 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2419 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2420 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2421 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2422 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2423
2424 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2425 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2426 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2427 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2428
2429 @itemize @minus
2430 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2431 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2432 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2433 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2434 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2435 switching data and direction as necessary
2436 @end itemize
2437
2438 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2439 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2440
2441 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2442 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2443 default values are used.
2444 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2445 @example
2446 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2447 @end example
2448 @end deffn
2449
2450 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2451 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2452 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2453 during device selection.
2454 @end deffn
2455
2456 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2457 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2458 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2459 is connected to the host.
2460 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2461 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2462 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2466 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2467 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2468 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2469 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2470 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2471
2472 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2476 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2477 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2478 @end deffn
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2481 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2482 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2483 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2484 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2485 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2486 and initially asserted reset signals.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2490 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2491 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2492 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2493 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2494 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2495 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2496 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2497 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2498 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2499 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2500
2501 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2502 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2503 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2504 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2505 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2506 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2507
2508 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2509 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2510 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2511 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2512 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2513 are always driven by the FTDI.
2514
2515 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2516 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2517 @var{name}.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2521 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2522 @itemize @minus
2523 @item @option{0}, drive low
2524 @item @option{1}, drive high
2525 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2526 @end itemize
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2530 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2534 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2535
2536 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2537 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2538 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2539 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2540 @itemize @minus
2541 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2542 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2543 @end itemize
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2547 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2548
2549 @end deffn
2550
2551 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2552 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2553 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2554 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2555
2556 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2557 processors which are being simulated.
2558
2559 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2560 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2561 sockets instead of TCP.
2562 @end deffn
2563
2564 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2565 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2566 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2570 something like:
2571
2572 @example
2573 interface remote_bitbang
2574 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2575 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2576 @end example
2577
2578 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2579 named mysocket:
2580
2581 @example
2582 interface remote_bitbang
2583 remote_bitbang_port 0
2584 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2585 @end example
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2589 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2590 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2591 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2592
2593 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2594 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2595 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2596 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2597 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2601 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2602 default values are used.
2603 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2604 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2605 @example
2606 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2607 @end example
2608 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2609 @example
2610 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2611 @end example
2612 @end deffn
2613
2614 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2615 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2616 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2617 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2618 target board.
2619
2620 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2621 @example
2622 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2623 reset_config srst_only
2624 @end example
2625 @end deffn
2626
2627 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2628 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2629 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2630 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2634 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2635 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2641 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2642 This has one driver-specific command:
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2645 Display either the address of the I/O port
2646 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2647 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2648 This is a write-once setting.
2649 @end deffn
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2653 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2654 transports.
2655
2656 @quotation Compatibility Note
2657 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2658 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2659 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2660 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2661 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2662 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2663 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2664 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2665 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2666 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2667 @end quotation
2668
2669 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2670 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2671 states.
2672 @end deffn
2673 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2674 Display free device internal memory.
2675 @end deffn
2676 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2677 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2678 command version.
2679 @end deffn
2680 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2681 Display the device configuration.
2682 @end deffn
2683 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2684 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2685 power state.
2686 @end deffn
2687 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2688 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2689 @end deffn
2690 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2691 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2692 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2693 IP configuration.
2694 @end deffn
2695 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2696 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2697 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2698 @end deffn
2699 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2700 Reset the current configuration.
2701 @end deffn
2702 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2703 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2704 @end deffn
2705 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2706 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2707 pairs.
2708
2709 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2710 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2711 @example
2712 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2713 @end example
2714 @end deffn
2715 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2716 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2717 pairs.
2718
2719 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2720 @example
2721 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2722 77a90000
2723 @end example
2724 @end deffn
2725 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2726 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2727 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2728 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2729 instead.
2730
2731 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2732 @end deffn
2733 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2734 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2735 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2736
2737 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2738 @end deffn
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2742 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2743 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2744 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2745 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2746
2747 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2748 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2749 This is a write-once setting.
2750 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2751
2752 @itemize @minus
2753 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2754 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2755 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2756 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2757 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2758 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2759 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2760 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2761 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2762 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2763 some versions of
2764 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2765 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2766 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2767 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2768 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2769 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2770 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2771 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2772 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2773 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2774 @end itemize
2775 @end deffn
2776
2777 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2778 Display either the address of the I/O port
2779 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2780 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2781 This is a write-once setting.
2782
2783 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2784 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2785 you may encounter a problem.
2786 @end deffn
2787
2788 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2789 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2790 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2791 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2792 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2793 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2794
2795 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2796 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2797 @quotation Tip
2798 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2799 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2800 @example
2801 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2802 > adapter_khz 500
2803 @end example
2804 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2805 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2806 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2807 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2808 large set of samples.
2809 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2810 @example
2811 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2812 @end example
2813 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2814 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2815
2816 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2817 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2818 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2819 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2820 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2821 @end quotation
2822 @end deffn
2823
2824 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2825 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2826 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2827 @end deffn
2828
2829 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2830 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2831
2832 @example
2833 interface parport
2834 parport_port 0x278
2835 parport_cable wiggler
2836 @end example
2837 @end deffn
2838
2839 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2840 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2841 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2842 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2843 @end deffn
2844 @end deffn
2845
2846 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2847 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2848 @end deffn
2849
2850 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2851 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2852 @end deffn
2853
2854 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2855 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2856
2857 @quotation Note
2858 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2859 which are not currently documented here.
2860 @end quotation
2861 @end deffn
2862
2863 @anchor{hla_interface}
2864 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2865 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2866 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2867 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2868
2869 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2870 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2871 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2872 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2873 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2874
2875 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2876 Currently Not Supported.
2877 @end deffn
2878
2879 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2880 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2881 @end deffn
2882
2883 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2884 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2888 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2889 @end deffn
2890
2891 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2892 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2893 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2894 @end deffn
2895 @end deffn
2896
2897 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2898 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2899 @end deffn
2900
2901 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2902 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2903 @end deffn
2904
2905 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2906 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @quotation Note
2910 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2911 which are not currently documented here.
2912 @end quotation
2913
2914 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2915 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2916 No arguments: print status.
2917 @end deffn
2918
2919 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2920 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2921 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2922
2923 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2924 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2925 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2926 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2927 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2928 configuration on exit.
2929
2930 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2931 pinout.
2932
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
2936 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
2937 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2938
2939 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
2940 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
2941 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
2942
2943 @itemize @minus
2944 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
2945 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
2946 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
2947 @end itemize
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
2951 The USB device description string of the adapter.
2952 This value is only used with the standard variant.
2953 @end deffn
2954 @end deffn
2955
2956 @section Transport Configuration
2957 @cindex Transport
2958 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2959 and the debug adapter you are using,
2960 several transports may be available to
2961 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2962 @deffn Command {transport list}
2963 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2964 version of OpenOCD.
2965 @end deffn
2966
2967 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2968 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2969
2970 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2971 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2972 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2973 adapter's driver).
2974
2975 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2976 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2977 supported by the debug adapter.
2978
2979 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2980 transport, if any.
2981 @end deffn
2982
2983 @subsection JTAG Transport
2984 @cindex JTAG
2985 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
2986 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
2987 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
2988 each of which must be explicitly declared.
2989 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
2990 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2991
2992 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2993 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2994 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2995 hla_jtag}.
2996
2997 @subsection SWD Transport
2998 @cindex SWD
2999 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3000 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3001 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3002 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3003 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3004 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3005 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3006
3007 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3008 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3009 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3010 hla_swd}.
3011
3012 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3013 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3014 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3015 expected to change.
3016 @end deffn
3017 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3018 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3019 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3020 No parameters: displays current settings.
3021 @end deffn
3022
3023 @subsection SPI Transport
3024 @cindex SPI
3025 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3026 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3027 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3028 solution for flash programming.
3029
3030 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3031 @section JTAG Speed
3032 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3033 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3034 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3035 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3036 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3037 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3038 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3039 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3040 power management software that may be active.
3041
3042 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3043 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3044 target event handler.
3045 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3046 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3047 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3048 sets up those clocks).
3049 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3050 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3051 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3052 in the target config file.
3053 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3054 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3055 config file instead.
3056 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3057 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3058 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3059
3060 @example
3061 jtag_rclk 3000
3062 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3063 @end example
3064
3065 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3066 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3067 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3068 may not be the fastest solution.
3069
3070 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3071 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3072 which support adaptive clocking.
3073
3074 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3075 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3076 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3077 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3078 than the speed specified.
3079
3080 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3081 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3082 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3083 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3084
3085 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3086 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3087 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3088 JTAG clocking after setup.
3089 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3090 If the interface device can not
3091 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3095 @cindex adaptive clocking
3096 @cindex RTCK
3097 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3098 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3099 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3100 @example
3101 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3102 jtag_rclk 3000
3103 @end example
3104 @end defun
3105
3106 @node Reset Configuration
3107 @chapter Reset Configuration
3108 @cindex Reset Configuration
3109
3110 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3111 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3112 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3113 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3114 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3115 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3116 Please see the various board files for examples.
3117
3118 @quotation Note
3119 To maintainers and integrators:
3120 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3121 Normally the board configuration file
3122 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3123 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3124
3125 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3126 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3127 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3128 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3129 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3130 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3131 @end quotation
3132
3133 @section Types of Reset
3134
3135 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3136 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3137 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3138
3139 @itemize @bullet
3140 @item
3141 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3142 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3143 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3144 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3145 @item
3146 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3147 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3148 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3149 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3150 @item
3151 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3152 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3153 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3154 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3155 @item
3156 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3157 several other types of reset.
3158 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3159 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3160 There may be individual module resets.
3161 @end itemize
3162
3163 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3164 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3165 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3166 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3167 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3168 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3169 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3170 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3171 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3172
3173 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3174 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3175
3176 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3177 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3178 common issues are:
3179
3180 @itemize @bullet
3181
3182 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3183 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3184 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3185 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3186 when either of those signals is not connected.
3187 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3188 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3189 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3190 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3191
3192 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3193 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3194 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3195 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3196
3197 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3198 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3199 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3200 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3201 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3202 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3203 hardware debouncing.
3204 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3205 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3206
3207 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3208 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3209 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3210 to use push/pull output drivers.
3211 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3212 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3213 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3214 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3215
3216 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3217 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3218 issues (not limited to errata).
3219 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3220 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3221 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3222 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3223 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3224 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3225 @end itemize
3226
3227 There can also be other issues.
3228 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3229 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3230 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3231 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3232 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3233 Agreement (NDA).
3234
3235 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3236 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3237 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3238
3239 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3240 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3241
3242 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3243
3244 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3245 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3246 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3247 allowing it to be deasserted.
3248 @end deffn
3249
3250 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3251 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3252 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3253 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3254 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3255 @end deffn
3256
3257 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3258 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3259 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3260 allowing it to be deasserted.
3261 @end deffn
3262
3263 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3264 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3265 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3269 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3270 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3271 configuration scripts.
3272
3273 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3274 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3275 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3276 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3277 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3278 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3279 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3280 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3281
3282 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3283 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3284 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3285 -- may be specified at a time.
3286 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3287 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3288 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3289 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3290 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3291
3292 @itemize
3293 @item
3294 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3295 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3296 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3297 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3298 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3299
3300 @quotation Tip
3301 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3302 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3303 @end quotation
3304
3305 @item
3306 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3307 signal implementations.
3308 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3309 indicating everything behaves normally.
3310 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3311 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3312 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3313 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3314 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3315 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3316 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3317
3318 @item
3319 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3320 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3321 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3322 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3323 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3324 while SRST is asserted.
3325 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3326 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3327
3328 @item
3329 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3330 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3331 is required to use this option.
3332 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3333 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3334 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3335 be asserted before any target connection.
3336 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3337 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3338 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3339 @end itemize
3340
3341 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3342 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3343 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3344 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3345 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3346
3347 @itemize
3348 @item
3349 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3350 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3351 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3352 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3353
3354 @item
3355 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3356 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3357 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3358 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3359 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3360 @end itemize
3361 @end deffn
3362
3363 @section Custom Reset Handling
3364 @cindex events
3365
3366 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3367 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3368 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3369 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3370 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3371 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3372
3373 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3374 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3375 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3376 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3377 want to reset everything at once.
3378
3379 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3380 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3381 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3382 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3383 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3384 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3385 needs special attention.
3386
3387 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3388 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3389 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3390 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3391 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3392 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3393 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3394 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3395
3396 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3397 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3398 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3399 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3400 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3401
3402 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3403 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3404 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3405 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3406 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3407 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3408 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3409 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3410 or potentially some other value.
3411
3412 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3413 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3414 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3415 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3416 (or their associated targets)
3417 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3418
3419 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3420 they return.
3421 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3422 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3423 @end deffn
3424
3425 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3426 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3427 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3428 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3429 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3430 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3431 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3432 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3433 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3434 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3435 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3439 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3440 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3441 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3442 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3443 @end deffn
3444
3445
3446 @node TAP Declaration
3447 @chapter TAP Declaration
3448 @cindex TAP declaration
3449 @cindex TAP configuration
3450
3451 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3452 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3453
3454 @itemize @bullet
3455 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3456 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3457 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3458 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3459 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3460 start running that code.
3461 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3462 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3463 and missing connections.
3464 @end itemize
3465
3466 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3467 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3468 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3469 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3470 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3471
3472 @section Scan Chains
3473 @cindex scan chain
3474
3475 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3476 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3477 They also need to be added to
3478 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3479 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3480 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3481 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3482 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3483 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3484 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3485 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3486
3487 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3488 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3489 command, presented in the next chapter.
3490 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3491 debugging targets.)
3492 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3493
3494 @verbatim
3495 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3496 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3497 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3498 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3499 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3500 @end verbatim
3501
3502 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3503 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3504 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3505 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3506 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3507 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3508 until they are told to do so.
3509
3510 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3511 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3512 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3513 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3514
3515 @example
3516 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3517 @end example
3518
3519 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3520 by a given chip.
3521 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3522 and so forth.
3523 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3524 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3525 both inside a single chip and between them.
3526 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3527
3528 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3529 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3530 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3531 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3532 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3533 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3534 includes commands something like this:
3535
3536 @example
3537 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3538 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3539 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3540 @end example
3541
3542 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3543 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3544 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3545
3546 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3547 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3548 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3549 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3550 @example
3551 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3552 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3553 @}
3554 @end example
3555 @end deffn
3556
3557 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3558 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3559 and their status.
3560 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3561 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3562 but systems with a JTAG router can
3563 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3564 @end deffn
3565
3566 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3567 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3568
3569 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3570 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3571
3572 @section TAP Names
3573 @cindex dotted name
3574
3575 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3576 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3577 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3578 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3579 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3580 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3581 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3582 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3583
3584 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3585 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3586 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3587
3588 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3589
3590 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3591 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3592 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3593 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3594
3595 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3596 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3597 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3598 overridable.
3599
3600 @cindex TAP naming convention
3601 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3602 and should follow this convention:
3603
3604 @itemize @bullet
3605 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3606 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3607 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3608 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3609 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3610 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3611 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3612 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3613 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3614 with a single TAP;
3615 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3616 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3617 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3618 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3619 @end itemize
3620
3621 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3622
3623 @itemize @bullet
3624 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3625 @*The length in bits of the
3626 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3627 @end itemize
3628
3629 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3630
3631 @itemize @bullet
3632 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3633 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3634 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3635 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3636 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3637 (the TAP is linked in).
3638 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3639 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3640 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3641 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3642 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3643 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3644 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3645 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3646 values that were found but not included in the list.
3647
3648 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3649 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3650 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3651 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3652 hardware to find these values.
3653 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3654 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3655 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3656 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3657 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3658 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3659 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3660 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3661 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3662 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3663 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3664 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3665 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3666 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3667 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3668 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3669 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3670 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3671 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3672 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3673 @end itemize
3674 @end deffn
3675
3676 @section Other TAP commands
3677
3678 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3679 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3680 At this writing this TAP attribute
3681 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3682 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3683 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3684 See the next section for information about the available events.
3685
3686 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3687 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3688 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3689 @end deffn
3690
3691 @section TAP Events
3692 @cindex events
3693 @cindex TAP events
3694
3695 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3696 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3697 The other applies to debugger targets,
3698 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3699
3700 The TAP events currently defined are:
3701
3702 @itemize @bullet
3703 @item @b{post-reset}
3704 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3705 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3706 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3707 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3708 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3709
3710 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3711 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3712 of any particular target.
3713 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3714 @item @b{setup}
3715 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3716 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3717 @item @b{tap-disable}
3718 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3719 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3720 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3721 @item @b{tap-enable}
3722 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3723 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3724 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3725 @end itemize
3726
3727 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3728 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3729 contents to be accurate), you might:
3730
3731 @example
3732 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3733 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3734 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3735 @}
3736 @end example
3737
3738
3739 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3740 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3741 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3742 @cindex jrc
3743
3744 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3745 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3746 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3747 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3748 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3749
3750 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3751 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3752 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3753 be visible.
3754 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3755 ignores, such as:
3756
3757 @itemize
3758 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3759 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3760 TAPs receive new instructions.
3761 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3762 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3763 @end itemize
3764
3765 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3766 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3767 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3768 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3769
3770 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3771 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3772
3773 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3774 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3775 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3776 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3777 should define TAP event handlers using
3778 code that looks something like this:
3779
3780 @example
3781 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3782 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3783 @}
3784 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3785 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3786 @}
3787 @end example
3788
3789 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3790
3791 @example
3792 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3793 @end example
3794
3795 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3796 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3797 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3798 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3799
3800 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3801 If necessary, disables the tap
3802 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3803 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3804 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3805 and "0" if it is disabled.
3806 @end deffn
3807
3808 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3809 If necessary, enables the tap
3810 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3811 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3812 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3813 and "0" if it is disabled.
3814 @end deffn
3815
3816 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3817 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3818 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3819 and "0" if it is disabled.
3820
3821 @quotation Note
3822 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3823 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3824 @end quotation
3825 @end deffn
3826
3827 @anchor{autoprobing}
3828 @section Autoprobing
3829 @cindex autoprobe
3830 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3831
3832 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3833 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3834 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3835 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3836
3837 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3838 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3839 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3840 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3841 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3842 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3843 right when they come out of reset).
3844
3845 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3846
3847 @example
3848 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3849 reset_config trst_and_srst
3850 jtag_rclk 8
3851 @end example
3852
3853 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3854 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3855
3856 @enumerate
3857 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3858 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3859 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3860 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3861 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3862 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3863 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3864 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3865 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3866 that is discovered.
3867 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3868 register, it will report it.
3869 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3870 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3871 @end enumerate
3872
3873 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3874 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3875 that's a bit more complex:
3876
3877 @example
3878 clock speed 8 kHz
3879 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3880 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3881 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3882 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3883 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3884 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3885 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3886 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3887 @end example
3888
3889 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3890 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3891 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3892 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3893 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3894 and so forth.
3895
3896 @node CPU Configuration
3897 @chapter CPU Configuration
3898 @cindex GDB target
3899
3900 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3901 You can also access these targets without GDB
3902 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3903 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3904 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3905 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3906
3907 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3908 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3909
3910 @section Target List
3911 @cindex target, current
3912 @cindex target, list
3913
3914 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3915 where each member has a name.
3916 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3917 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3918 (plural!) command.
3919 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3920 look like with more than one:
3921 @verbatim
3922 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3923 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3924 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3925 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3926 @end verbatim
3927
3928 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3929 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3930 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3931 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3932 space seen by that current target.
3933 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3934 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3935 are examples; and there are many more.
3936
3937 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3938
3939 @deffn Command {target current}
3940 Returns the name of the current target.
3941 @end deffn
3942
3943 @deffn Command {target names}
3944 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3945 @example
3946 foreach t [target names] @{
3947 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3948 @}
3949 @end example
3950 @end deffn
3951
3952 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3953 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3954
3955 @deffn Command targets [name]
3956 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3957 command names are singular.}
3958
3959 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3960 targets in a user friendly form.
3961
3962 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3963 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3964 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3965 @end deffn
3966
3967 @section Target CPU Types
3968 @cindex target type
3969 @cindex CPU type
3970
3971 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3972 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3973 when calling @command{target create}.
3974 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3975 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3976 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3977 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3978 what core-specific commands may be available
3979 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3980 and more.
3981
3982 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3983 since there's a command to list them.
3984
3985 @anchor{targettypes}
3986 @deffn Command {target types}
3987 Lists all supported target types.
3988 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
3989
3990 @itemize @bullet
3991 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
3992 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3993 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3994 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3995 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
3996 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
3997 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3998 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
3999 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4000 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4001 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4002 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4003 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4004 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4005 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4006 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4007 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4008 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4009 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4010 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4011 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4012 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4013 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4014 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4015 @itemize @minus
4016 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4017 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4018 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4019 @end itemize
4020 And two debug interfaces cores:
4021 @itemize @minus
4022 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4023 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4024 @end itemize
4025 @end itemize
4026 @end deffn
4027
4028 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4029 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4030 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4031 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4032 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4033 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4034 reflect design generations;
4035 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4036 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4037
4038 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4039 @section Target Configuration
4040
4041 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4042 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4043 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4044 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4045 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4046
4047 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4048 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4049 optional parts.
4050 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4051 command, created as part of target creation.
4052
4053 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4054 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4055 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4056 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4057 to be much more board-specific.
4058 The key steps you use might look something like this
4059
4060 @example
4061 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4062 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4063 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4064 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4065 @end example
4066
4067 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4068 on-chip SRAM.
4069 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4070 writes to target memory;
4071 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4072 GDB memory checksumming;
4073 and more.
4074
4075 @quotation Warning
4076 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4077 inaccessible when application code
4078 (such as an operating system)
4079 enables or disables the MMU.
4080 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4081 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4082 easy access to other addresses needed.
4083 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4084 @end quotation
4085
4086 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4087 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4088 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4089 controllers.
4090 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4091 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4092 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4093
4094 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4095 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4096 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4097 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4098 purposes including additional configuration.
4099
4100 @itemize @bullet
4101 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4102 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4103 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4104 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4105
4106 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4107 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4108 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4109 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4110 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4111 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4112 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4113
4114 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4115 @end itemize
4116 @end deffn
4117
4118 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4119 The options accepted by this command may also be
4120 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4121 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4122 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4123
4124 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4125 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4126 and changing its endianness.
4127
4128 @itemize @bullet
4129
4130 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4131 used to access this target.
4132
4133 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4134 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4135
4136 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4137 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4138 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4139 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4140 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4141 same event name assigns only one handler.
4142
4143 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4144 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4145 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4146 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4147 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4148 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4149 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4150
4151 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4152 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4153 or virtual address is being used.
4154
4155 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4156 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4157
4158 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4159 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4160 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4161 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4162 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4163
4164 @anchor{rtostype}
4165 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4166 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4167 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}|
4168 @option{uCOS-III}
4169 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4170
4171 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4172 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4173 access the target for debugging.
4174
4175 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4176 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4177 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4178 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4179 @end itemize
4180 @end deffn
4181
4182 @section Other $target_name Commands
4183 @cindex object command
4184
4185 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4186 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4187
4188 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4189 Once a button is created a button
4190 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4191 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4192 configure it like this:
4193
4194 @example
4195 # Create
4196 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4197 # Modify
4198 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4199 # Query
4200 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4201 # Report
4202 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4203 @end example
4204
4205 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4206 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4207
4208 @example
4209 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4210 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4211 @end example
4212
4213 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4214
4215 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4216 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4217 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4218 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4219 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4220 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4221 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4222 They are not otherwise documented here.
4223 @end deffn
4224
4225 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4226 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4227 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4228 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4229 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4230 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4231 the target side uses raw memory.
4232
4233 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4234 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4235 The script orientation comes from working with data
4236 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4237 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4238 and neither store nor return those values.
4239
4240 @itemize
4241 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4242 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4243 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4244 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4245 @end itemize
4246 @end deffn
4247
4248 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4249 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4250 @command{$target_name configure}
4251 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4252 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4253 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4254 There are a few special cases:
4255
4256 @itemize @bullet
4257 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4258 event named @var{event_name}.
4259 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4260 two parameters.
4261 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4262 This is a special case because this is set using
4263 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4264 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4265 @end itemize
4266
4267 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4268 all the targets you might use something like this:
4269
4270 @example
4271 foreach name [target names] @{
4272 set y [$name cget -endian]
4273 set z [$name cget -type]
4274 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4275 $x $name $y $z]
4276 @}
4277 @end example
4278 @end deffn
4279
4280 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4281 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4282 Displays the current target state:
4283 @code{debug-running},
4284 @code{halted},
4285 @code{reset},
4286 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4287 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4288 @end deffn
4289
4290 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4291 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4292 currently associated with this target.
4293 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4297 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4298 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4299 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4300 @end deffn
4301
4302 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4303 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4304 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4305 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4306 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4307 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4308 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4309 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4310 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4314 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4315 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4316 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4317 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4318 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4319 @end deffn
4320
4321 @anchor{targetevents}
4322 @section Target Events
4323 @cindex target events
4324 @cindex events
4325 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4326 For example:
4327 @itemize @bullet
4328 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4329 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4330 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4331 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4332 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4333 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4334 to set up system clocks or
4335 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4336 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4337 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4338 @end itemize
4339
4340 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4341 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4342 @command{target create ... -event}.
4343
4344 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4345 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4346 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4347
4348 @example
4349 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4350 echo "Reset..."
4351 reset halt
4352 @}
4353 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4354 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4355 echo "Reset..."
4356 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4357 # we need a reset init.
4358 reset init
4359 @}
4360 @end example
4361
4362 The following target events are defined:
4363
4364 @itemize @bullet
4365 @item @b{debug-halted}
4366 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4367 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4368 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4369 @item @b{early-halted}
4370 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4371 @item @b{examine-start}
4372 @* Before target examine is called.
4373 @item @b{examine-end}
4374 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4375 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4376 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4377 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4378 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4379 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4380 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4381 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4382 @* When GDB disconnects
4383 @item @b{gdb-end}
4384 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4385 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4386 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4387 @code{reset init})
4388 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4389 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4390 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4391 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4392 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4393 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4394 @item @b{gdb-start}
4395 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4396 @item @b{halted}
4397 @* The target has halted
4398 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4399 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4400 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4401 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4402 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4403 @item @b{reset-assert}
4404 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4405 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4406 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4407 it instead of asserting SRST.
4408 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4409 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4410 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4411 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4412 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4413 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4414 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4415 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4416 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4417 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4418 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4419 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4420 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4421 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4422 released on the scan chain.
4423 @item @b{reset-end}
4424 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4425 @ignore
4426 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4427 @* Currently not used
4428 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4429 @* Currently not used
4430 @end ignore
4431 @item @b{reset-init}
4432 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4433 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4434
4435 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4436 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4437 multiplexing, and so on.
4438 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4439 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4440 @item @b{reset-start}
4441 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4442 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4443
4444 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4445 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4446 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4447 @ignore
4448 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4449 @* Currently not used
4450 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4451 @* Currently not used
4452 @end ignore
4453 @item @b{resume-start}
4454 @* Before any target is resumed
4455 @item @b{resume-end}
4456 @* After all targets have resumed
4457 @item @b{resumed}
4458 @* Target has resumed
4459 @item @b{trace-config}
4460 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4461 @end itemize
4462
4463 @node Flash Commands
4464 @chapter Flash Commands
4465
4466 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4467 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4468 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4469 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4470 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4471 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4472 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4473 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4474 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4475
4476 Flash Steps:
4477 @enumerate
4478 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4479 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4480 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4481 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4482 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4483 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4484 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4485 @item GDB Flashing
4486 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4487 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4488 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4489 @end enumerate
4490
4491 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4492 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4493 so that it can't boot.
4494 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4495 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4496
4497 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4498 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4499 @cindex flash configuration
4500
4501 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4502 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4503 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4504 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4505 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4506 see the driver-specific documentation.
4507
4508 @itemize @bullet
4509 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4510 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4511 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4512 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4513 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4514 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4515 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4516 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4517 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4518 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4519 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4520 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4521 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4522 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4523 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4524 commands to the flash controller.
4525 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4526 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4527 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4528 for more information.
4529 @end itemize
4530 @quotation Note
4531 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4532 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4533 @end quotation
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4537 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4538 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4539 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4540 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4541 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4542 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4543 @end deffn
4544
4545 @deffn Command {flash list}
4546 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4547 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4548 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4549 @end deffn
4550
4551 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4552 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4553 depends on the flash type.
4554 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4555 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4556 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4557 but most don't bother.
4558 @end deffn
4559
4560 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4561 @cindex flash erasing
4562 @cindex flash reading
4563 @cindex flash writing
4564 @cindex flash programming
4565 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4566
4567 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4568 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4569 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4570 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4571 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4572
4573 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4574 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4575 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4576 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4577 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4578
4579 @quotation Note
4580 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4581 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4582 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4583 back to a flash bank.
4584 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4585 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4586 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4587 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4588 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4589 @end quotation
4590
4591 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4592 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4593 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4594 disabled first.
4595 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4596 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4597 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4598
4599 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4600 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4601 up to and including @var{last}.
4602 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4603 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4604 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4605 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4606 @end deffn
4607
4608 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4609 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4610 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4611 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4612 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4613 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4614 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4615 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4616 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4617 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4618 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4619 before erase starts.
4620 @end deffn
4621
4622 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4623 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4624 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4625 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4626 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4627 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4628 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4629 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4630 before issuing this command.
4631 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4632 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4633 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4634 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4635 @end deffn
4636 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4637
4638 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4639 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4640 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4641 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4642 @end deffn
4643
4644 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4645 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4646 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4647 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4648 @end deffn
4649
4650 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4651 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4652 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4653 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4654 @end deffn
4655
4656 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4657 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4658 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4659 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4660 to the base address for each section in the image.
4661 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4662 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4663 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4664 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4665 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4666 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4667 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4668 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4669 each image section.
4670
4671 @quotation Warning
4672 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4673 data you want to preserve.
4674 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4675 sections might be erased with no notice.
4676 @itemize
4677 @item
4678 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4679 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4680 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4681 @item
4682 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4683 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4684 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4685 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4686 @end itemize
4687 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4688 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4689 @end quotation
4690
4691 @end deffn
4692
4693 @section Other Flash commands
4694 @cindex flash protection
4695
4696 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4697 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4698 and display that status.
4699 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4700 @end deffn
4701
4702 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4703 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4704 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4705
4706 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4707 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4708 and possibly stale information.
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @anchor{flashprotect}
4712 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4713 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4714 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4715 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4716 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4717 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4718 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4719 @end deffn
4720
4721 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4722 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4723 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4724 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4725 @end deffn
4726
4727 @anchor{program}
4728 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4729 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4730 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4731 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4732 @end deffn
4733
4734 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4735 @section Flash Driver List
4736 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4737 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4738 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4739
4740 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4741 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4742 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4743
4744 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4745
4746 @itemize
4747 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4748 @end itemize
4749
4750 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4751 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4752 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4753 @example
4754 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4755 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4756 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4757 @end example
4758 @end deffn
4759
4760 @subsection External Flash
4761
4762 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4763 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4764 @cindex CFI
4765 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4766 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4767 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4768 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4769 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4770 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4771 configure a bus and its timings), or
4772 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4773 on the flash chip.
4774 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4775 speed up operation.
4776
4777 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4778
4779 @itemize
4780 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4781 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4782 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4783 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4784 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4785 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4786 @end itemize
4787
4788 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4789 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4790
4791 @example
4792 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4793 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4794 @end example
4795
4796 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4797 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4798 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4799
4800 @example
4801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4802 @end example
4803
4804 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4805 @end deffn
4806
4807 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4808 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4809 @cindex SPI
4810 @cindex jtagspi
4811 @cindex bscan_spi
4812 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4813 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4814 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4815 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4816 accessed through JTAG.
4817
4818 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4819 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4820 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4821 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4822 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4823 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4824
4825 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4826 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4827 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4828 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4829 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4830 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4831 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4832 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4833
4834 @itemize
4835 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4836 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4837 @var{USER1} instruction.
4838 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4839 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4840 @end itemize
4841
4842 @example
4843 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4844 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4845 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4846 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4847 @end example
4848 @end deffn
4849
4850 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4851 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4852 @cindex SPIFI
4853 @cindex lpcspifi
4854 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4855 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4856 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4857
4858 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4859 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4860 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4861 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4862 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4863
4864 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4865 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4866 are configured by the driver.
4867
4868 @example
4869 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4870 @end example
4871
4872 @end deffn
4873
4874 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4875 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4876 @cindex SMI
4877 @cindex stmsmi
4878 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4879 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4880 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4881 SPI flash devices.
4882 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4883 flash devices can be connected.
4884
4885 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4886 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4887 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4888 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4889 the flash content.
4890
4891 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4892 to identify the memory bank.
4893 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4894 flash size, are detected automatically.
4895
4896 @example
4897 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4898 @end example
4899
4900 @end deffn
4901
4902 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4903 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4904 Microcontroller platform.
4905
4906 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4907 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4908
4909 @example
4910 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4911 @end example
4912
4913 @end deffn
4914
4915 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4916
4917 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4918 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4919 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4920 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4921 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4922 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4923
4924 @example
4925 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4926 @end example
4927 @end deffn
4928
4929 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
4930 @cindex ambiqmicro
4931 @cindex apollo
4932 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
4933 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4934 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
4935 with the target using SWD.
4936
4937 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
4938 the device class of the MCU.
4939 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
4940 to set up the flash banks.
4941 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
4942 sizes of an Apollo chip.
4943
4944 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
4945 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
4946 and the second bank starts after the first.
4947
4948 @example
4949 # Flash bank 0
4950 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4951 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
4952 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4953 @end example
4954
4955 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
4956 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
4957 are available to the user.
4958
4959 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
4960
4961 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
4962 Erase entire bank.
4963 @end deffn
4964 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
4965 Erase device pages.
4966 @end deffn
4967 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
4968 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
4969 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
4970 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
4971 the flash.
4972 @end deffn
4973 @end deffn
4974
4975 @anchor{at91samd}
4976 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4977 @cindex at91samd
4978 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
4979 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
4980 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4981
4982 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4983 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4984 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4985 processor to be halted.
4986 @end deffn
4987
4988 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4989 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4990 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4991 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4992 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4993 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4994
4995 @example
4996 at91samd set-security enable
4997 @end example
4998 @end deffn
4999
5000 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5001 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5002 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5003 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5004 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5005 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5006 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5007 in order to disable this feature.
5008
5009 @example
5010 at91samd eeprom
5011 at91samd eeprom 1024
5012 @end example
5013 @end deffn
5014
5015 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5016 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5017 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5018 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5019 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5020 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5021
5022 @example
5023 at91samd bootloader
5024 at91samd bootloader 16384
5025 @end example
5026 @end deffn
5027
5028 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5029 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5030 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5031 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5032 @end deffn
5033
5034 @end deffn
5035
5036 @anchor{at91sam3}
5037 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5038 @cindex at91sam3
5039 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5040 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5041 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5042 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5043 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5044 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5045 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5046 chips are confirmed.}
5047
5048 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5049 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5050 the following fixed locations:
5051
5052 @example
5053 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5054 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5055 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5056 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5057 @end example
5058
5059 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5060 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5061 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5062
5063 @itemize
5064 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5065 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5066 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5067 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5068 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5069 @end itemize
5070
5071 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5072
5073 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5074 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5075 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5076 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5077 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5078 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5079 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5080
5081 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5082 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5083 @end deffn
5084
5085 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5086 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5087 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5088 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5089 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5090 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5091 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5092 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5093 @end deffn
5094
5095 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5096 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5097 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5098 @end deffn
5099 @end deffn
5100
5101 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5102 @cindex at91sam4
5103 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5104 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5105 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5106 @end deffn
5107
5108 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5109 @cindex at91sam4l
5110 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5111 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5112 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5113
5114 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5115 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5116 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5117 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5118 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5119 @end deffn
5120 @end deffn
5121
5122 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5123 @cindex atsamv
5124 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5125 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5126 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5127 @end deffn
5128
5129 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5130 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5131 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5132 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5133 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5134
5135 @example
5136 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5137 @end example
5138
5139 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5140 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5141
5142 @itemize
5143 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5144 @item @var{banks}
5145 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5146 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5147 @item @var{pages_size}
5148 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5149 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5150 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5151 @end itemize
5152
5153 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5154 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5155 will be autoconfigured.
5156 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5157
5158 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5159 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5160 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5161 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5162 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5163
5164 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5165 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5166 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5167 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5168 are not truly general purpose).
5169 @quotation Note
5170 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5171 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5172 @end quotation
5173 @end deffn
5174 @end deffn
5175
5176 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5177 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5178 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5179 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5180 @end deffn
5181
5182 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5183 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5184 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5185 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5186 autoconfigures itself.
5187 @example
5188 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5189 @end example
5190 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5191 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5192 this via the following command:
5193 @example
5194 efm32 debuglock num
5195 @end example
5196 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5197 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5198 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5199 supported.}
5200 @end deffn
5201
5202 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5203 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5204 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5205 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5206 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5207 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5208 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5209
5210 @example
5211 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5212 @end example
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5216 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5217 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5218 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5219 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5220 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5221 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5222 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5223 characters) ignored.
5224
5225 @example
5226 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5227 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5228 @end example
5229 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5230 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5231 @end deffn
5232
5233 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5234 @cindex kinetis
5235 Kx and KLx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5236 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5237 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5238 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5239
5240 @example
5241 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5242 @end example
5243
5244 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5245 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5246 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5247 set by 'flash protect' command.
5248 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5249 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5250 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5251 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5252 with the rest of a flash image.
5253 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5254 @end deffn
5255
5256 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5257 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5258 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5259 @end deffn
5260
5261 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5262 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5263 @end deffn
5264
5265 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5266 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5267 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5268 @end deffn
5269
5270 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5271 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5272 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5273 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5274 command completes.
5275 @end deffn
5276
5277 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5278 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5279 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5280 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5281 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5282
5283 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5284 Program Partition command.
5285
5286 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5287 Reset the device after partition setting.
5288
5289 Show partition size:
5290 @example
5291 kinetis nvm_partition info
5292 @end example
5293
5294 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5295 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5296 @example
5297 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5298 @end example
5299
5300 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5301 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5302 @example
5303 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5304 @end example
5305 @end deffn
5306
5307 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5308 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5309 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5310 @end deffn
5311
5312 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5313 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5314 Command disables watchdog timer.
5315 @end deffn
5316 @end deffn
5317
5318 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5319 @cindex kinetis_ke
5320 KE members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5321 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5322 the KE family and sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5323 autoconfigures itself.
5324
5325 @example
5326 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5327 @end example
5328
5329 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5330 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5331 @end deffn
5332
5333 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5334 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5335 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5336 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5337 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5338 @end deffn
5339
5340 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5341 Command disables watchdog timer.
5342 @end deffn
5343 @end deffn
5344
5345 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5346 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5347 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5348 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5349 microcontroller families from NXP.
5350
5351 @quotation Note
5352 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5353 driver:
5354 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5355 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5356 @end quotation
5357
5358 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5359 which must appear in the following order:
5360
5361 @itemize
5362 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5363 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5364 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5365 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5366 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5367 LPC43x[2357])
5368 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5369 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5370 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5371 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5372 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5373 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5374 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5375 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5376 at which the core is running
5377 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5378 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5379 @quotation Note
5380 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5381 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5382 However, if you do provide it,
5383 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5384 @end quotation
5385 @end itemize
5386
5387 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5388
5389 @example
5390 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5391 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5392 @end example
5393
5394 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5395 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5396 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5397 @end deffn
5398 @end deffn
5399
5400 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5401 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5402 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5403 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5404 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5405 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5406
5407 @example
5408 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5409 @end example
5410 @end deffn
5411
5412 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5413 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5414 from NXP.
5415
5416 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5417 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5418 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5419 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5420 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5421 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5422 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5423 you start the PLL.
5424
5425 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5426
5427 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5428 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5429 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5430
5431 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5432 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5433 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5434 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5435 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5436 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5437 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5438
5439 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5440 @example
5441 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5442 @end example
5443
5444 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5445 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5446 @code{flash banks} command.
5447
5448 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5449 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5450 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5451 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5452 a known signature.
5453 Example:
5454 @example
5455 lpc2900 signature 0
5456 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5457 @end example
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5461 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5462 saves it to a file in binary format.
5463 Example:
5464 @example
5465 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5466 @end example
5467 @end deffn
5468
5469 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5470 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5471 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5472 command:
5473
5474 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5475 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5476 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5477 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5478
5479 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5480 Example:
5481 @example
5482 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5483 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5484 @end example
5485 @end deffn
5486
5487 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5488 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5489 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5490 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5491 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5492 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5493 912 bytes.
5494 @quotation Attention
5495 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5496 @end quotation
5497 Example:
5498 @example
5499 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5500 @end example
5501 @end deffn
5502
5503 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5504 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5505 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5506 after the next power cycle.
5507 @quotation Attention
5508 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5509 @end quotation
5510 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5511 Example:
5512 @example
5513 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5514 flash info 0
5515 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5516 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5517 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5518 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5519 @end example
5520 @end deffn
5521
5522 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5523 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5524 effective after the next power cycle.
5525 @quotation Attention
5526 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5527 @end quotation
5528 Examples:
5529 @example
5530 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5531 @end example
5532 @end deffn
5533 @end deffn
5534
5535 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5536 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5537 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5538 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5539
5540 @example
5541 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5542 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5543 @end example
5544
5545 @itemize @bullet
5546 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5547 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5548 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5549 @end itemize
5550
5551 Example usage:
5552 @example
5553 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5554 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5555 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5556 @} else @{
5557 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5558 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5559 @}
5560 @end example
5561 @end deffn
5562
5563 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5564 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5565 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5566 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5567 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5568 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5569 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5570 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5571 also have division into regions: main and info.
5572 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5573 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5574
5575 @example
5576 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5577 @end example
5578
5579 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5580
5581 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5582 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5583 @end deffn
5584
5585 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5586 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5587 @end deffn
5588
5589 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5590 Erase all userflash including info region.
5591 @end deffn
5592
5593 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5594 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5598 Check sectors protect.
5599 @end deffn
5600
5601 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5602 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5603 @end deffn
5604
5605 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5606 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5607 @end deffn
5608
5609 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5610 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5614 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5615 @end deffn
5616
5617 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5618 Show information about flash driver.
5619 @end deffn
5620
5621 @end deffn
5622
5623 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5624 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5625 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5626
5627 @example
5628 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5629 @end example
5630
5631 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5632
5633 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5634 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5635 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5636 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5637 code.
5638 @end deffn
5639
5640 @end deffn
5641
5642 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5643 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5644 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5645
5646 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5647 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5648 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5649 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5650
5651 @example
5652 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5653 @end example
5654 @end deffn
5655
5656 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5657 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5658 and integrate flash memory.
5659
5660 @example
5661 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5662 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5663 @end example
5664
5665 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5666 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5667 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5668 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5669 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5670 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5671 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5672 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5673 @end deffn
5674 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5675 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5676 This will remove any Code Protection.
5677 @end deffn
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5681 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5682 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5683 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5684 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5685
5686 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5687 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5688
5689 @example
5690 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5691 @end example
5692
5693 psoc4-specific commands
5694 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5695 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5696
5697 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5698 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5699
5700 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5701 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5702 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5703
5704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5708 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5709
5710 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5711 @end deffn
5712 @end deffn
5713
5714 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5715 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5716 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5717 and SWD interface.
5718 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5719 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5720
5721 @example
5722 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5723 @end example
5724
5725 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5726
5727 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5728 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5729 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5733 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5734 @end deffn
5735 @end deffn
5736
5737 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5738 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5739 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5740 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5741 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5742 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5743 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5744 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5745
5746 @example
5747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5748 @end example
5749
5750 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5751 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5752 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5753 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5754 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5755 disabled.
5756
5757 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5758 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5759 @quotation Warning
5760 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5761 applied to all of them.
5762 @end quotation
5763 @end deffn
5764 @end deffn
5765
5766 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5767 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5768 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5769 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5770 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5771
5772 @example
5773 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5774 @end example
5775
5776 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5777 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5778 the flash driver.
5779
5780 @example
5781 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5782 @end example
5783
5784 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5785 as per the following example.
5786 @example
5787 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5788 @end example
5789
5790 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5791 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5792 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5793 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5794 are defined:
5795
5796 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5797 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5798 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5799 @end deffn
5800
5801 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5802 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5803 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5804 @end deffn
5805
5806 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5807 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5808 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5809 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5810 @end deffn
5811
5812 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5813 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5814 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5815 @end deffn
5816 @end deffn
5817
5818 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5819 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5820 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
5821 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5822 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5823
5824 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5825 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5826 the flash driver.
5827
5828 @example
5829 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5830 @end example
5831
5832 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5833
5834 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5835 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5836 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5837 @end deffn
5838
5839 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5840 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5841 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5842 @end deffn
5843
5844 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
5845 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1.
5846 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5847 @end deffn
5848
5849 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
5850 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
5851 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
5852 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, user_options a
5853 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, boot_addr0 and boot_addr1
5854 two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
5855 @end deffn
5856 @end deffn
5857
5858 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5859 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5860 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5861 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5862 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5863
5864 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5865 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5866 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5867 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5868 second bank.
5869
5870 @example
5871 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5872 @end example
5873
5874 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5875
5876 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5877 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5878 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5879 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5880 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5881 @end deffn
5882 @end deffn
5883
5884 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5885 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5886 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5887 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5888 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5889
5890 @example
5891 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5892 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5893 @end example
5894
5895 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5896 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5897 for the specified flash bank.
5898 @end deffn
5899 @end deffn
5900
5901 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5902 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5903 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5904 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5905 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5906
5907 @example
5908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5909 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5910 @end example
5911
5912 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5913 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5914 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5915
5916 @itemize @bullet
5917 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5918 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5919 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5920 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5921 @end itemize
5922 @end deffn
5923
5924 @end deffn
5925
5926 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5927 @cindex str9xpec
5928
5929 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5930 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5931 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5932 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5933
5934 Here is some background info to help
5935 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5936 the str9:
5937 @enumerate
5938 @item
5939 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5940 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5941 @item
5942 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5943 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5944 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5945 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5946 @end enumerate
5947
5948 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5949 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5950 configured for flash bank 0.
5951 @example
5952 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5953 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5954 jtag_reset 0 1
5955 # turn off target polling
5956 poll off
5957 # disable str9 core
5958 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5959 # read option bytes
5960 str9xpec options_read 0
5961 # re-enable str9 core
5962 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5963 poll on
5964 reset halt
5965 @end example
5966 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5967 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5968 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5969 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5970
5971 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5972
5973 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5974 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5975 @end deffn
5976
5977 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5978 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5979 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5980 @end deffn
5981
5982 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5983 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5984 erase the device.
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5988 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5992 Configure str9 boot bank.
5993 @end deffn
5994
5995 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5996 Configure str9 lvd source.
5997 @end deffn
5998
5999 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6000 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6001 @end deffn
6002
6003 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6004 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6008 Read str9 option bytes.
6009 @end deffn
6010
6011 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6012 Write str9 option bytes.
6013 @end deffn
6014
6015 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6016 unlock str9 device.
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @end deffn
6020
6021 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6022 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6023 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6024 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6025
6026 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6027
6028 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6029 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6030 @end deffn
6031
6032 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6033 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6034 @end deffn
6035
6036 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6037 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6038 the flash clock.
6039 @end deffn
6040 @end deffn
6041
6042 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6043 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6044 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6045 @end deffn
6046
6047 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6048 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6049 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6050
6051 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6052
6053 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6054 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6055 @end deffn
6056
6057 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6058 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6059 @end deffn
6060
6061 @end deffn
6062
6063 @section NAND Flash Commands
6064 @cindex NAND
6065
6066 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6067 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6068 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6069
6070 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6071 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6072 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6073 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6074 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6075 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6076
6077 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6078 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6079 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6080 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6081 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6082 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6083 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6084 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6085 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6086 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6087
6088 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6089 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6090 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6091 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6092 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6093 every 512 bytes of data.
6094
6095 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6096 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6097 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6098 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6099 ECC mode is used.
6100
6101 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6102 @enumerate
6103 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6104 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6105 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6106 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6107 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6108 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6109 to access that device.
6110 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6111 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6112 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6113 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6114 de-brick a board.
6115 @end enumerate
6116
6117 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6118 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6119 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6120 are only 32 bits wide.
6121 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6122 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6123 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6124 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6125
6126 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6127 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6128 @cindex NAND configuration
6129
6130 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6131 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6132 OpenOCD has initialized.
6133
6134 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6135 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6136 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6137 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6138 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6139 they were a single (larger) device.
6140 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6141 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6142
6143 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6144 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6145 configuration files, not interactively.
6146
6147 @itemize @bullet
6148 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6149 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6150 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6151 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6152 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6153 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6154 commands to the NAND controller.
6155 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6156 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6157 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6158 for more information.
6159 @end itemize
6160 @end deffn
6161
6162 @deffn Command {nand list}
6163 Prints a summary of each device declared
6164 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6165 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6166 @example
6167 > nand list
6168 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6169 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6170 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6171 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6172 >
6173 @end example
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6177 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6178 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6179 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6180 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6181 it with most other NAND commands.
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6185
6186 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6187 @cindex NAND reading
6188 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6189 starting at the specified offset.
6190 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6191
6192 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6193 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6194
6195 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6196 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6197 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6198
6199 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6200 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6201 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6202 method which handled that error correction.
6203
6204 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6205 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6206 @itemize @bullet
6207 @item no oob_* parameter
6208 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6209 @item @code{oob_raw}
6210 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6211 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6212 spare areas associated with each data page.
6213 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6214 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6215 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6216 @item @code{oob_only}
6217 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6218 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6219 spare areas associated with each data page.
6220 @end itemize
6221 @end deffn
6222
6223 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6224 @cindex NAND erasing
6225 @cindex NAND programming
6226 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6227 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6228 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6229 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6230 If those parameters are not specified,
6231 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6232 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6233
6234 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6235 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6236 block marker.
6237 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6238 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6239 @end deffn
6240
6241 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6242 @cindex NAND writing
6243 @cindex NAND programming
6244 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6245 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6246 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6247 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6248
6249 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6250 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6251
6252 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6253 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6254 past the end of the device.
6255 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6256 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6257 if that's being written.)
6258
6259 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6260 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6261 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6262
6263 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6264 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6265 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6266 @itemize @bullet
6267 @item no oob_* parameter
6268 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6269 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6270 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6271 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6272 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6273 @item @code{oob_only}
6274 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6275 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6276 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6277 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6278 @item @code{oob_raw}
6279 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6280 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6281 un-altered OOB.
6282 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6283 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6284 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6285 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6286 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6287 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6288 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6289 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6290 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6291 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6292 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6293 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6294 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6295 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6296 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6297 @end itemize
6298 @end deffn
6299
6300 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6301 @cindex NAND verification
6302 @cindex NAND programming
6303 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6304 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6305 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6306
6307 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6308 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6309
6310 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6311 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6312 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6313 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6314 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6315
6316 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6317 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6318 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6319
6320 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6321 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6322 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6323 be removed in a future release.
6324 @end deffn
6325
6326 @subsection Other NAND commands
6327 @cindex NAND other commands
6328
6329 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6330 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6331 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6332 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6333 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6334 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6335 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6336 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6337
6338 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6339 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6340 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6341 @end deffn
6342
6343 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6344 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6345 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6346 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6347 status for each block.
6348 @end deffn
6349
6350 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6351 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6352 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6353
6354 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6355 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6356 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6357 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6358 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6359
6360 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6361 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6362 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6363 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6364 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6365 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6366 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6367 @end deffn
6368
6369 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6370 @subsection NAND Driver List
6371 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6372 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6373 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6374
6375 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6376 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6377 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6378 address of the ECC controller.
6379 @example
6380 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6381 @end example
6382 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6383 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6384 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6385 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6386 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6387 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6388 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6389 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6390 @end deffn
6391 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6392 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6393 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6394 @end deffn
6395
6396 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6397 properly configured for input or output.
6398 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6399 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6400 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6401 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6402 @end deffn
6403 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6404 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6405 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6406 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6407 @end deffn
6408 @end deffn
6409
6410 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6411 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6412 chips from Texas Instruments.
6413 It takes three extra parameters:
6414 address of the NAND chip;
6415 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6416 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6417 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6418 @example
6419 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6420 @end example
6421 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6422 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6423 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6424 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6425 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6426 @end deffn
6427
6428 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6429 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6430 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6431 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6432 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6433 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6434 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6435 @end deffn
6436
6437 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6438 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6439 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6440 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6441 @end deffn
6442 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6443
6444 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6445 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6446 should work for this chip aswell.
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6450 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6451 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6452 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6453 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6454 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6455 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6456 @example
6457 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6458 @end example
6459 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6460 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6461 without parameter query status.
6462 @end deffn
6463 @end deffn
6464
6465 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6466 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6467 parameter: the address of the controller.
6468 @example
6469 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6470 @end example
6471 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6472 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6473 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6474 change any behavior.
6475 @end deffn
6476
6477 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6478 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6479 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6480 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6481 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6482 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6483 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6484 specialized commands.
6485 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6486 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6487 change any behavior.
6488 @end deffn
6489
6490 @section mFlash
6491
6492 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6493 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6494
6495 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6496 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6497 address @var{base}.
6498 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6499 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6500
6501 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6502
6503 @example
6504 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6505 @end example
6506
6507 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6508
6509 @example
6510 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6511 @end example
6512 @end deffn
6513
6514 @subsection mFlash commands
6515 @cindex mFlash commands
6516
6517 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6518 Configure mflash PLL.
6519 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6520 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6521 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6522 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6526 Configure bootable option.
6527 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6528 (4kB) for boot.
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6532 Configure storage information.
6533 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6534 written.
6535 @end deffn
6536
6537 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6538 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6539 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6540 @end deffn
6541
6542 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6543 Probe mflash.
6544 @end deffn
6545
6546 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6547 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6548 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @node Flash Programming
6552 @chapter Flash Programming
6553
6554 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6555 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6556 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6557
6558 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6559 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6560
6561 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6562 @enumerate
6563 @item 'init' is executed.
6564 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6565 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6566 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6567 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6568 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6569 @end enumerate
6570
6571 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6572
6573 @example
6574 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6575 # are optional parameters
6576 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6577 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6578
6579 # binary files need the flash address passing
6580 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6581 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6582 @end example
6583
6584 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6585 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6586 @cindex PLD
6587 @cindex FPGA
6588
6589 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6590 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6591 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6592 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6593 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6594 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6595 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6596
6597 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6598
6599 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6600 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6601 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6602
6603 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6604 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6605
6606 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6607 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6608 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6609 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6610 behavior.
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6614 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6615 @end deffn
6616
6617 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6618 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6619 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6620 @end deffn
6621
6622 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6623
6624 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6625 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6626 that particular type of PLD.
6627
6628 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6629 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6630 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6631
6632 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6633 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6634 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6635
6636 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6637 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6638 for FPGA @var{num}.
6639 @end deffn
6640 @end deffn
6641
6642 @node General Commands
6643 @chapter General Commands
6644 @cindex commands
6645
6646 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6647 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6648 commands are documented elsewhere.
6649
6650 Intent:
6651 @itemize @bullet
6652 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6653 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6654 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6655 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6656
6657 @item @b{From the human}
6658 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6659 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6660
6661 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6662 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6663 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6664
6665 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6666 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6667 port is 5555.
6668 @end itemize
6669
6670
6671 @section Server Commands
6672
6673 @deffn {Command} exit
6674 Exits the current telnet session.
6675 @end deffn
6676
6677 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6678 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6679 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6680 Not every command provides helptext.
6681
6682 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6683 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6684 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6685 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6689 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6690 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6691 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6692 Useful in connection with script files
6693 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6697 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6698 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6699 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @anchor{debuglevel}
6703 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6704 @cindex message level
6705 Display debug level.
6706 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6707 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6708 Level 0 is error messages only;
6709 level 1 adds warnings;
6710 level 2 adds informational messages;
6711 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6712 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6713 the command line along with the location of that log
6714 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6715 @xref{Running}.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6719 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6720 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6721 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6722 @example
6723 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6724 @end example
6725 @end deffn
6726
6727 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6728 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6729 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6730 @end deffn
6731
6732 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6733 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6734 @end deffn
6735
6736 @deffn Command bindto [name]
6737 Specify address by name on which to listen for incoming TCP/IP connections.
6738 By default, OpenOCD will listen on all available interfaces.
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6742 @section Target State handling
6743 @cindex reset
6744 @cindex halt
6745 @cindex target initialization
6746
6747 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6748 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6749 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6750 a current target which is used to perform the
6751 various operations. The current target may be changed
6752 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6753 target which should become current.
6754
6755 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6756 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6757 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6758 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6759 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6760
6761 @emph{With no arguments}:
6762 list all available registers for the current target,
6763 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6764 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6765 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6766 are flagged as such.
6767
6768 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6769 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6770 bypassing any internal cache.
6771
6772 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6773 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6774 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6775 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6776 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6777 relevant module will flush such values.
6778
6779 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6780 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6781
6782 @example
6783 > reg
6784 ===== ARM registers
6785 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6786 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6787 (2) r2 (/32)
6788 ...
6789 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6790 >
6791 @end example
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6795 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6796 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6797 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6798 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6799 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6800 (and enter debug mode).
6801 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6802
6803 @quotation Warning
6804 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6805 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6806 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6807 power mode by gating the core clock;
6808 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6809
6810 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6811 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6812 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6813 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6814 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6815 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6816
6817 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6818 work with a JTAG debugger.
6819 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6820 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6821 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6822 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6823 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6824 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6825 @end quotation
6826
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn Command resume [address]
6830 Resume the target at its current code position,
6831 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6832 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835 @deffn Command step [address]
6836 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6837 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @anchor{resetcommand}
6841 @deffn Command reset
6842 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6843 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6844 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6845 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6846 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6847 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6848
6849 The optional parameter specifies what should
6850 happen after the reset.
6851 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6852 The other options will not work on all systems.
6853 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6854
6855 @itemize @minus
6856 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6857 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6858 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6859 @end itemize
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6863 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6864 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6865 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6866 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6867 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6868 state.
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @section I/O Utilities
6872
6873 These commands are available when
6874 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6875 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6876 notably the ZY1000.
6877 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6878
6879 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6880
6881 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6882 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6883 the text file @file{filename}.
6884 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6885 The last string is followed by a newline.
6886 @end deffn
6887
6888 @deffn Command cat filename
6889 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6890 @end deffn
6891
6892 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6893 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6894 into @file{dest_filename}.
6895 @end deffn
6896
6897 @deffn Command ip
6898 @emph{No description provided.}
6899 @end deffn
6900
6901 @deffn Command ls
6902 @emph{No description provided.}
6903 @end deffn
6904
6905 @deffn Command mac
6906 @emph{No description provided.}
6907 @end deffn
6908
6909 @deffn Command meminfo
6910 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6911 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6912 @end deffn
6913
6914 @deffn Command peek
6915 @emph{No description provided.}
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn Command poke
6919 @emph{No description provided.}
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 @deffn Command rm filename
6923 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6924 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6925 @end deffn
6926
6927 @deffn Command trunc filename
6928 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6929 @end deffn
6930
6931 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6932 @section Memory access commands
6933 @cindex memory access
6934
6935 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6936 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6937 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6938 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6939
6940 @enumerate
6941 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6942 to change the current target.
6943 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6944 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6945 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6946 @end enumerate
6947
6948 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6949 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6950 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6951 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6952 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6953 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6954 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6955 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6956 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6957 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6958 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6959 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6960 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6964 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6965 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6966 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6967 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6968 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6969 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6970 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6971 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6972 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @anchor{imageaccess}
6976 @section Image loading commands
6977 @cindex image loading
6978 @cindex image dumping
6979
6980 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6981 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6982 binary file named @var{filename}.
6983 @end deffn
6984
6985 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6986 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6987 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6988 @end deffn
6989
6990 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6991 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6992 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6993 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6994 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6995 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6996 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6997 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6998 separately.
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7002 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7003 The file format may optionally be specified
7004 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7005 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7006 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7007 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7008 @example
7009 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7010 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7011 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7012 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7013 $address $length
7014 @}
7015 @end example
7016 @end deffn
7017
7018 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7019 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7020 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7021 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7022 The file format may optionally be specified
7023 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7027 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7028 The file format may optionally be specified
7029 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7030 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7034 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7035 The file format may optionally be specified
7036 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7037 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7038 @end deffn
7039
7040
7041 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7042 @cindex breakpoint
7043 @cindex watchpoint
7044
7045 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7046 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7047 watchpoints.
7048 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7049
7050 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7051 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7052 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7053 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7054 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7055 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7056
7057 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7058 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7059 @end deffn
7060
7061 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7062 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7066 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7070 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7071 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7072 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7073 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7074 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7075 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7076 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7077 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7078 @end deffn
7079
7080 @section Misc Commands
7081
7082 @cindex profiling
7083 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7084 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7085 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7086 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7087 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7088 limit the address range.
7089 @end deffn
7090
7091 @deffn Command {version}
7092 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7093 @end deffn
7094
7095 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7096 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7097 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7098 @end deffn
7099
7100 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7101 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7102 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7103 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7104
7105 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7106 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7107 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7108 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7109
7110 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7111 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7112 @cindex tracing
7113 @cindex ETM
7114 @cindex ETB
7115
7116 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7117 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7118 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7119
7120 @itemize
7121 @item
7122 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7123 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7124 supports such an interface.
7125 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7126 and trace port support.)
7127 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7128 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7129 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7130 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7131 in the board-specific configuration file.
7132 @item
7133 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7134 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7135 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7136 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7137 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7138 @end itemize
7139
7140 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7141
7142 @quotation Issues
7143 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7144 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7145
7146 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7147 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7148 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7149 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7150 dummy trace port driver}.
7151
7152 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7153 as well as tracing only during specific states
7154 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7155
7156 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7157 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7158 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7159 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7160 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7161
7162 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7163 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7164 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7165 this original style of JTAG access.
7166 @end quotation
7167
7168 @subsection ETM Configuration
7169 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7170
7171 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7172 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7173 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7174
7175 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7176 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7177 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7178 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7179 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7180 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7181 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7182 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7183 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7184
7185 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7186 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7187 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7188
7189 @quotation Warning
7190 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7191 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7192 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7193 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7194 @end quotation
7195
7196 @quotation Note
7197 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7198 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7199 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7200 what CPU activities are traced.
7201 @end quotation
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn Command {etm info}
7205 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7206 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7207 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7208 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7209 @end deffn
7210
7211 @deffn Command {etm status}
7212 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7213 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7214 Did trace data overflow?
7215 Was it triggered?
7216 @end deffn
7217
7218 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7219 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7220 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7221 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7222 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7223
7224 @itemize
7225 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7226 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7227 The value is one of
7228 @option{none} (save nothing),
7229 @option{data} (save data),
7230 @option{address} (save addresses),
7231 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7232 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7233 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7234 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7235 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7236 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7237 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7238 trace stream without an image of the code.
7239 @end itemize
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7243 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7244 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7245 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7246 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7247
7248 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7249 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7250 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7254
7255 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7256 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7257 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7258
7259 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7260 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7261 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7262 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7263 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7264 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7265 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7266
7267 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7268
7269 @itemize
7270 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7271 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7272 for instruction access within that function's body.
7273 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7274 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7275 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7276 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7277 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7278 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7279 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7280 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7281 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7282 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7283 @item @emph{... more}
7284 @end itemize
7285
7286 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7287 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7288
7289 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7290 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7291 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7292 @end deffn
7293
7294 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7295 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7296 @end deffn
7297
7298 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7299 Opens an image file.
7300 @end deffn
7301
7302 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7303 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @deffn Command {etm start}
7307 Starts trace data collection.
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7311 Stops trace data collection.
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7315 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7316
7317 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7318
7319 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7320 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7321 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7322 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7323 any trace data collection.}
7324 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7325 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7326 @end deffn
7327 @end deffn
7328
7329 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7330 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7331 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7332 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7333 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7334 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7335 @end deffn
7336 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7337 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7338 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7339 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7340 trace trigger becomes active.
7341
7342 @itemize
7343 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7344 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7345 afterwards.
7346 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7347 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7348 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7349 what caused that event to happen.
7350 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7351 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7352 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7353 how the event caused trouble.
7354 @end itemize
7355 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @end deffn
7359
7360 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7361 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7362 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7363 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7364 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7365
7366 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7367 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7368
7369 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7370 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7371 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7372 @end deffn
7373
7374 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7375 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7376 @end deffn
7377
7378 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7379 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7380 @end deffn
7381 @end deffn
7382
7383
7384 @section Generic ARM
7385 @cindex ARM
7386
7387 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7388 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7389 commands that may be available.
7390
7391 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7392 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7393 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7394 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7395 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7396 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7397 @end deffn
7398
7399 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7400 @cindex disassemble
7401 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7402 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7403 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7404 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7405 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7406 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7407 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7408
7409 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7410 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7411 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7412 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7413 with a handful of exceptions.
7414 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7415 @end deffn
7416
7417 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7418 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7419 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7420 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7421 and using the MCR instruction.
7422 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7423 an ARM register.)
7424 @end deffn
7425
7426 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7427 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7428 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7429 and the MRC instruction.
7430 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7431 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7432 an ARM register.)
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7436 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7437 core mode if necessary.
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7441 @cindex ARM semihosting
7442 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7443
7444 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7445 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7446 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7447 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7448 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7449 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7450 @end deffn
7451
7452 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7453 @cindex ARM semihosting
7454 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
7455 status.
7456
7457 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
7458 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
7459 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
7460 debugger.
7461 @end deffn
7462
7463 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7464 @cindex ARMv4
7465 @cindex ARMv5
7466
7467 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7468 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7469 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7470 variant.
7471
7472 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7473 @cindex ARM7
7474 @cindex ARM9
7475
7476 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7477 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7478 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7479 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7480
7481 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7482 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7483 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7484 instead of breakpoints.
7485 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7486
7487 This should be
7488 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7489 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7490 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7491 @end deffn
7492
7493 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7494 @cindex DCC
7495 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7496 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7497 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7498
7499 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7500 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7501 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7502 @end deffn
7503
7504 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7505 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7506 that don't check completion of the operation.
7507 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7508
7509 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7510 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7511 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7512 @end deffn
7513
7514 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7515 @cindex ARM720T
7516
7517 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7518 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7519 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7520 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7521
7522 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7523 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7524 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7525
7526 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7527 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7528 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7529 @end deffn
7530
7531 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7532 @cindex ARM9
7533
7534 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7535 integer processors.
7536 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7537
7538 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7539 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7540 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7541 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7542
7543 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7544 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7545 @cindex vector_catch
7546 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7547 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7548 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7549 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7550 to those hardware vectors.
7551
7552 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7553 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7554 vector catch hardware to intercept
7555 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7556 @option{none} of them,
7557 or a list with one or more of the following:
7558 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7559 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7563 @cindex ARM920T
7564
7565 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7566 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7567 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7568 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7569 and ARM9 commands.
7570
7571 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7572 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7573 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7577 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7578 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7579 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7580 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7581 (Not all registers can be written.)
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7585 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7586 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7587
7588 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7589 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7590 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7591 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7592 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7593 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7597 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7598 @end deffn
7599
7600 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7601 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7605 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7606
7607 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7608 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7609 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7610 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7611 and ARM9 commands.
7612
7613 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7614 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7615
7616 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7617 Print information about the caches found.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7621 @cindex ARM966E
7622
7623 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7624 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7625 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7626 and ARM9 commands.
7627
7628 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7629 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7630 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7631 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7632 ARM966E-S TRM.
7633 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7634 as required for BIST support.
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @subsection XScale specific commands
7638 @cindex XScale
7639
7640 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7641
7642 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7643 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7644 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7645 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7646 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7647 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7648 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7649
7650 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7651 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7652 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7653 the mini-IC.
7654
7655 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7656 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7657 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7658 code layout in memory:
7659 @example
7660 _vectors:
7661 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7662 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7663 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7664 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7665 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7666 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7667 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7668 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7669 .org 0x100
7670 .long real_reset_vector
7671 .long real_ui_handler
7672 .long real_swi_handler
7673 .long real_pf_abort
7674 .long real_data_abort
7675 .long 0 /* unused */
7676 .long real_irq_handler
7677 .long real_fiq_handler
7678 @end example
7679
7680 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7681 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7682 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7683 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7684 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7685 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7686 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7687 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7688 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7689 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7690 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7691 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7692 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7693 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7694 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7695 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7696 software.
7697
7698 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7699 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7700 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7701 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7702
7703 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7704 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7705 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7706 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7707 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7708 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7709 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7710 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7711 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7712
7713 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7714 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7715
7716 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7717 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7721 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7722 @end deffn
7723
7724 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7725 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7726 @end deffn
7727
7728 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7729 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7730 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7731 @end deffn
7732
7733 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7734 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7735 @end deffn
7736
7737 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7738 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7739 @end deffn
7740
7741 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7742 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7743 @end deffn
7744
7745 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7746 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7747 @end deffn
7748
7749 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7750 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7751 @end deffn
7752
7753 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7754 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7755 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7756 and modifying how it is emptied.
7757 @end deffn
7758
7759 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7760 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7761 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7762 The image @var{type} may be one of
7763 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7764 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7765 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7766 @end deffn
7767
7768 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7769 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7770 @cindex vector_catch
7771 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7772 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7773
7774 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7775 @example
7776 0x01 Trap Reset
7777 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7778 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7779 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7780 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7781 0x20 reserved
7782 0x40 Trap IRQ
7783 0x80 Trap FIQ
7784 @end example
7785 @end deffn
7786
7787 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7788 @cindex vector_table
7789
7790 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7791 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7792 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7793 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7794 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7795
7796 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7797
7798 @end deffn
7799
7800 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7801 @cindex ARMv6
7802
7803 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7804 @cindex ARM11
7805
7806 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7807 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7808 which is enabled by default.
7809 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7810 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7811 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7812 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7813 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7814 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7815 @end deffn
7816
7817 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7818 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7819 which is enabled by default.
7820 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7821 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7825 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7826 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7827 they are disabled by default.
7828 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7829 @end deffn
7830
7831 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7832 @cindex vector_catch
7833 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7834 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7835 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7836
7837 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7838 for certain hardware events.
7839 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7840 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7841 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7845 @cindex ARMv7
7846
7847 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7848 @cindex Debug Access Port
7849 @cindex DAP
7850 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7851 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7852 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7853
7854 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7855 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7856 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 @deffn Command {dap apreg} ap_num reg [value]
7860 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
7861 or set a new value @var{value}.
7862 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
7863 @end deffn
7864
7865 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7866 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7867 @end deffn
7868
7869 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7870 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7871 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7872 @end deffn
7873
7874 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7875 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7876 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7877 @end deffn
7878
7879 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7880 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7881 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7882 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7883 @end deffn
7884
7885 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7886 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7887 Defaulting to 0.
7888 @end deffn
7889
7890 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7891 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7892 Disabled by default
7893 @end deffn
7894
7895
7896 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7897 @cindex Cortex-A
7898
7899 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7900 display information about target caches
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
7904 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
7905 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
7906 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
7907 Defaults to 'off'.
7908 @end deffn
7909
7910 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7911 Initialize core debug
7912 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7913 @end deffn
7914
7915 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7916 Disable SMP mode
7917 @end deffn
7918
7919 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7920 Enable SMP mode
7921 @end deffn
7922
7923 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7924 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7925 @end deffn
7926
7927 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7928 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7932 configure l2x cache
7933 @end deffn
7934
7935
7936 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7937 @cindex Cortex-R
7938
7939 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7940 Initialize core debug
7941 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7942 @end deffn
7943
7944 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7945 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7946 @end deffn
7947
7948
7949 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7950 @cindex tracing
7951 @cindex SWO
7952 @cindex SWV
7953 @cindex TPIU
7954 @cindex ITM
7955 @cindex ETM
7956
7957 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7958 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7959 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7960
7961 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7962 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7963 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7964 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7965
7966 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7967 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7968 debugger adapter features.
7969
7970 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7971 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7972
7973 Command options:
7974 @itemize @minus
7975 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7976 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7977 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7978 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7979 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7980 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7981 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7982 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7983 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7984 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7985 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7986 coding;
7987 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7988 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7989 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7990 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7991 data is to be output via SWO;
7992 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7993 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7994 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7995 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7996 rate automatically.
7997 @end itemize
7998
7999 Example usage:
8000 @enumerate
8001 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8002 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8003 enough to:
8004 @example
8005 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8006 ...
8007 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8008 ...
8009 @end example
8010 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8011 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8012 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8013 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8014 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8015 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8016 @example
8017 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8018 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8019 @end example
8020 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8021 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8022 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8023 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8024 @example
8025 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8026 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8027 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8028 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8029 @end example
8030 @end enumerate
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8034 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8035 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8039 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8040 @end deffn
8041
8042 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8043 @cindex Cortex-M
8044
8045 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8046 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8047
8048 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8049 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8050 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8051 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8052 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8053 the step command leaves with the core running.
8054
8055 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8056 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8057 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8058
8059 Default is @option{auto}.
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8063 @cindex vector_catch
8064 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8065 for certain hardware events.
8066
8067 Parameters request interception of
8068 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8069 @option{none} of them,
8070 or one or more of the following:
8071 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8072 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8073 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8074 @option{irq_err},
8075 @option{state_err},
8076 @option{chk_err}, or
8077 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8078 @option{reset}.
8079 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8080 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8081 are mapped to HardFault.
8082 UsageFault checks for
8083 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8084 must also be explicitly enabled.
8085
8086 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8087 @end deffn
8088
8089 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8090 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8091 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8092 @itemize @minus
8093 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8094 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8095 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8096 @end itemize
8097 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8098 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8099 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8100 the peripherals.
8101 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @section Intel Architecture
8105
8106 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8107 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8108 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8109 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8110 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8111 @itemize
8112 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8113 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8114 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8115 @end itemize
8116
8117 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8118 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8119 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8120
8121 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8122 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8123 @end deffn
8124
8125 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8126 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8127 @end deffn
8128
8129 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8130 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8131 @end deffn
8132
8133 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8134 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8135 @end deffn
8136
8137 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8138 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8139 @end deffn
8140
8141 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8142 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8143 @end deffn
8144
8145 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8146
8147 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8148 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8149
8150 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8151 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8152 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8153 @end deffn
8154 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8155 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8156
8157 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8158
8159 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8160 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8161 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8162 @end deffn
8163
8164 @subsection Registers commands
8165 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8166 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8167 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8168
8169 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8170
8171 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8172 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8173 and "timer" groups.
8174
8175 @emph{example:}
8176 @example
8177 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8178 @end example
8179
8180
8181 @end deffn
8182 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8183 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8184
8185 @emph{group} can be "system",
8186 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8187 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8188 @end deffn
8189
8190 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8191 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8192 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8193 @cindex tracing
8194 @cindex libdcc
8195 @cindex DCC
8196 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8197 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8198 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8199 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8200
8201 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8202 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8203 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8204 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8205 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8206 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8207
8208 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8209 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8210 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8211 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8212 The target being debugged may
8213 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8214 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8215 each supported by a command:
8216
8217 @itemize
8218 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8219 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8220 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8221 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8222
8223 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8224 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8225 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8226
8227 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8228 and then displayed at any time.
8229 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8230
8231 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8232 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8233 @end itemize
8234
8235 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8236 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8237 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8238 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8239 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8240 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8241 does the same thing.
8242
8243 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8244 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8245 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8246 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8247 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8248
8249 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8250 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8251 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8252 @end deffn
8253
8254 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8255 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8256 in the order they triggered.
8257 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8258 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8259 history records.
8260 @end deffn
8261
8262 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8263 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8264 they have been triggered.
8265 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8266 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8267 and associates it with that identifier.
8268
8269 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8270 are not related except by this command.
8271 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8272 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8273 @end deffn
8274
8275
8276 @node JTAG Commands
8277 @chapter JTAG Commands
8278 @cindex JTAG Commands
8279 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8280 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8281 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8282 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8283 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8284
8285 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8286 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8287
8288 @itemize @bullet
8289 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8290 devices such as a CPUs.
8291 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8292 standard state machine (in parallel)
8293 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8294 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8295 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8296 while the reading previous ones.
8297 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8298 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8299 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8300 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8301 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8302 registers.
8303 @end itemize
8304
8305 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8306
8307 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8308 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8309 the order of TAP state transitions.
8310 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8311 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8312 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8313 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8314 these commands are not available.
8315
8316 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8317 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8318 that specify the entire register.
8319 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8320 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8321 The return value holds the original value of each
8322 of those fields.
8323
8324 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8325 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8326 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8327 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8328 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8329
8330 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8331 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8332
8333 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8334 in that state.
8335 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8336 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8337 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8338
8339 @quotation Warning
8340 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8341 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8342 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8343 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8344 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8345 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8346 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8347 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8348 @end quotation
8349 @end deffn
8350
8351 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8352 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8353 This may be used for performance tuning.
8354
8355 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8356 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8357 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8358 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8359 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8360 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8361 @end deffn
8362
8363 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8364 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8365 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8366 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8367 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8368 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8369
8370 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8371 in that state.
8372 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8373 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8374 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8375
8376 @quotation Note
8377 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8378 register values, unlike data register values.
8379 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8380 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8381 @end quotation
8382 @end deffn
8383
8384 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8385 Set values of reset signals.
8386 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8387 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8388 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8389 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8390 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8391 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8392 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8393
8394 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8395 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8396 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8397 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8398 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8399 instead of the TRST signal.
8400 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8401 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8402 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8403 with handlers for that event.
8404 @end deffn
8405
8406 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8407 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8408 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8409 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8410 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8411 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8412 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8413 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8414 The final state must also be stable.
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8418 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8419 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8420 Instructions often need some time
8421 to execute before they take effect.
8422 @end deffn
8423
8424 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8425 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8426
8427 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8428 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8429 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8430 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8431 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8432 @end deffn
8433
8434 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8435 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8436 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8437 must also be enabled.
8438 Default is enabled.
8439 @end deffn
8440
8441 @section TAP state names
8442 @cindex TAP state names
8443
8444 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8445 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8446 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8447 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8448
8449 @itemize @bullet
8450 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8451 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8452 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8453 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8454 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8455 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8456 through the data register
8457 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8458 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8459 for update or more shifting
8460 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8461 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8462 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8463 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8464 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8465 through the instruction register
8466 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8467 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8468 for update or more shifting
8469 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8470 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8471 @end itemize
8472
8473 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8474 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8475 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8476 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8477
8478 @itemize @bullet
8479 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8480 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8481 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8482 may not be as expected.
8483 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8484 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8485 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8486 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8487 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8488 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8489 @end itemize
8490
8491 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8492 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8493
8494 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8495 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8496 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8497 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8498
8499 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8500 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8501 @cindex SVF
8502
8503 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8504 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8505 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8506 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8507
8508 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8509 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8510 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8511 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8512 each command is logged before it is executed.
8513 @end deffn
8514
8515 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8516 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8517 @cindex XSVF
8518
8519 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8520 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8521 Xilinx devices.
8522 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8523 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8524
8525 @quotation Important
8526 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8527 @end quotation
8528
8529 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8530 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8531 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8532 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8533 that TAP.
8534 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8535 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8536 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8537 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8541 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8542 after building the software.
8543 You may find them useful:
8544
8545 @itemize
8546 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8547 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8548 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8549 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8550 @end itemize
8551
8552 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8553 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8554 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8555 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8556 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8557 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8558 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8559
8560
8561 @node Utility Commands
8562 @chapter Utility Commands
8563 @cindex Utility Commands
8564
8565 @section RAM testing
8566 @cindex RAM testing
8567
8568 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8569 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8570 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8571 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8572 hardware problems.
8573
8574 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8575 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8576 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8577 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8578
8579 Load the memory testing functions with
8580
8581 @example
8582 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8583 @end example
8584
8585 to get access to the following facilities:
8586
8587 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8588 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8589 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8593 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8594 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8595 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8596 @end deffn
8597
8598 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8599 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8600 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8601 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8602 @end deffn
8603
8604 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8605 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8606 @end deffn
8607
8608 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8609 @cindex Firmware recovery
8610
8611 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8612 devices recovery with JTAG.
8613
8614 For quickstart instructions run:
8615 @example
8616 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8617 @end example
8618
8619 @node TFTP
8620 @chapter TFTP
8621 @cindex TFTP
8622 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8623 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8624
8625 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8626 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8627 server (tftpd). For example,
8628
8629 @example
8630 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8631 @end example
8632
8633 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8634 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8635
8636 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8637 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8638 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8639 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8640
8641 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8642 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8643 @cindex GDB
8644 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8645 to debug remote targets.
8646 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8647
8648 @itemize
8649 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8650 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8651 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8652 as shown in this chapter.
8653 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8654 that also will probably need to be configured.
8655 @end itemize
8656
8657 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8658 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8659 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8660 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8661 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8662 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8663
8664 @section Connecting to GDB
8665 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8666 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8667 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8668 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8669 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8670
8671 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8672
8673 @enumerate
8674 @item
8675 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8676 @example
8677 target remote localhost:3333
8678 @end example
8679 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8680
8681 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8682 @example
8683 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8684 @end example
8685 @item
8686 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8687 @example
8688 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8689 @end example
8690 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8691 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8692 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8693 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8694 @end enumerate
8695
8696 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8697 GDB command line.
8698
8699 @section Sample GDB session startup
8700
8701 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8702 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8703 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8704 small ARM program.
8705 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8706 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8707
8708 @example
8709 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8710 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8711 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8712 ...
8713 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8714 ...
8715 (gdb) load
8716 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8717 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8718 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8719 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8720 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8721 (gdb) continue
8722 Continuing.
8723 ...
8724 @end example
8725
8726 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8727 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8728 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8729 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8730
8731 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8732
8733 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8734 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8735 packet size and the device's memory map.
8736 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8737 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8738 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8739
8740 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8741 You may need to set those up by hand.
8742 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8743 something like:
8744
8745 @example
8746 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8747 @end example
8748
8749 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8750
8751 @example
8752 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8753 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8754 @end example
8755
8756 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8757 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8758 do not have such restrictions.
8759
8760 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8761 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8762 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8763
8764 @example
8765 define hook-step
8766 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8767 end
8768 define hookpost-step
8769 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8770 end
8771 @end example
8772
8773 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8774 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8775 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8776 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8777
8778 @section Programming using GDB
8779 @cindex Programming using GDB
8780 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8781
8782 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8783 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8784 @example
8785 gdb_memory_map disable
8786 @end example
8787 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8788 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8789 working area.
8790
8791 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8792 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8793 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8794 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8795
8796 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8797 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8798
8799 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8800 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8801 @example
8802 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8803 @end example
8804
8805 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8806 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8807
8808 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8809 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8810 will be used.
8811
8812 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8813 script can be executed:
8814 @example
8815 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8816 @end example
8817
8818 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8819 can be used.
8820 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8821 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8822 @cindex SMP
8823 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8824 @itemize @bullet
8825 @item j - smp status request
8826 @item J - smp set request
8827 @end itemize
8828
8829 OpenOCD implements :
8830 @itemize @bullet
8831 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8832 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8833 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8834 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8835 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8836 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8837 @end itemize
8838
8839 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8840 @itemize @bullet
8841 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8842 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8843 @example
8844 set $_core 1
8845 #Jc01 packet is sent
8846 print $_core
8847 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8848 @end example
8849
8850 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8851 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8852
8853 @example
8854 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8855 define toggle0
8856 maint packet Jc0
8857 continue
8858 main packet Jc-1
8859 end
8860 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8861 define toggle1
8862 maint packet Jc1
8863 continue
8864 main packet Jc-1
8865 end
8866 @end example
8867 @end itemize
8868
8869 @section RTOS Support
8870 @cindex RTOS Support
8871 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8872
8873 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8874 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8875
8876 @* An example setup is below:
8877
8878 @example
8879 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8880 @end example
8881
8882 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8883
8884 Currently supported rtos's include:
8885 @itemize @bullet
8886 @item @option{eCos}
8887 @item @option{ThreadX}
8888 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8889 @item @option{linux}
8890 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8891 @item @option{embKernel}
8892 @item @option{mqx}
8893 @item @option{uCOS-III}
8894 @end itemize
8895
8896 @quotation Note
8897 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8898 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8899 @end quotation
8900
8901 @table @code
8902 @item eCos symbols
8903 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8904 @item ThreadX symbols
8905 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8906 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8907 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8908 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8909 @tex
8910 \begingroup
8911 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8912 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8913 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8914 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8915 \par
8916 \endgroup
8917 @end tex
8918 @item linux symbols
8919 init_task.
8920 @item ChibiOS symbols
8921 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8922 @item embKernel symbols
8923 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8924 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8925 @item mqx symbols
8926 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8927 @item uC/OS-III symbols
8928 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
8929 @end table
8930
8931 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8932 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
8933
8934 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8935 along with the project:
8936
8937 @table @code
8938 @item FreeRTOS
8939 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8940 @item uC/OS-III
8941 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
8942 @end table
8943
8944 @node Tcl Scripting API
8945 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8946 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8947 @cindex Tcl scripts
8948 @section API rules
8949
8950 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8951 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8952 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8953
8954 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8955 pair list and lists.
8956
8957 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8958 list.
8959
8960 @example
8961 > set foo(me) Duane
8962 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8963 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8964 > set foo(duck) Donald
8965 @end example
8966
8967 If one does this:
8968
8969 @example
8970 > set foo
8971 @end example
8972
8973 The result is:
8974
8975 @example
8976 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8977 @end example
8978
8979 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8980
8981 @verbatim
8982 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8983 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8984 }
8985 @end verbatim
8986
8987 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8988 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8989
8990 @section Internal low-level Commands
8991
8992 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8993 invoke directly.
8994
8995 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8996 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8997 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8998
8999 @itemize @bullet
9000 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9001
9002 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
9003 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9004
9005 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
9006 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
9007
9008 Return information about the flash banks
9009
9010 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
9011
9012 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9013 its execution. Example:
9014
9015 @example
9016 > capture "reset init"
9017 @end example
9018
9019 @end itemize
9020
9021 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9022 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9023 called "flash_banks".
9024
9025 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9026
9027 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9028 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9029 holds one of the following values:
9030
9031 @itemize @bullet
9032 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9033 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9034 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9035 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9036 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9037 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9038 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9039 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9040 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9041 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9042 @end itemize
9043
9044 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9045
9046 @quotation Note
9047 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9048 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9049 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9050 is jim, not real tcl).
9051 @end quotation
9052
9053 @section Tcl RPC server
9054 @cindex RPC
9055
9056 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9057 commands and receive the results.
9058
9059 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9060 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9061 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9062 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9063 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9064
9065 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9066 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9067 @command{capture} command.
9068
9069 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9070
9071 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9072 @cindex RPC Notifications
9073
9074 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9075 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9076
9077 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9078 in the following format.
9079
9080 @verbatim
9081 type target_event event [event-name]
9082 type target_state state [state-name]
9083 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9084 @end verbatim
9085
9086 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9087 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9088 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9089 Defaults to off.
9090
9091 @end deffn
9092
9093 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9094 @cindex RPC trace output
9095
9096 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9097 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9098
9099 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9100
9101 @verbatim
9102 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9103 @end verbatim
9104
9105 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9106 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9107 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9108 Defaults to off.
9109
9110 See an example application here:
9111 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9112
9113 @end deffn
9114
9115 @node FAQ
9116 @chapter FAQ
9117 @cindex faq
9118 @enumerate
9119 @anchor{faqrtck}
9120 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9121 @cindex RTCK
9122 @cindex adaptive clocking
9123 @*
9124
9125 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9126 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9127 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9128 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9129
9130 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9131 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9132 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9133 @enumerate
9134 @item
9135 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9136 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9137 @item
9138 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9139 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9140 @end enumerate
9141
9142 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9143 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9144 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9145 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9146 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9147 power).
9148
9149 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9150 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9151 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9152 ARM926 scenario).
9153 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9154 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9155 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9156
9157 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9158 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9159 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9160 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9161
9162 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9163
9164 In order to make use of this,
9165 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9166 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9167
9168 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9169 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9170 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9171 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9172 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9173
9174 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9175 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9176 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9177 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9178
9179 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9180 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9181 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9182 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9183 with a CPLD.
9184 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9185 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9186 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9187 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9188 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9189 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9190
9191 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9192
9193 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9194
9195 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9196 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9197 depending on the chips on your board.
9198 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9199 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9200 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9201
9202 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9203 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9204 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9205
9206 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9207 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9208 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9209 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9210
9211 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9212 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9213 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9214 this way.
9215
9216 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9217 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9218 clock rate.
9219 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9220 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9221 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9222
9223 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9224
9225 @example
9226 # Example: 1.234MHz
9227 adapter_khz 1234
9228 @end example
9229
9230
9231 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9232
9233 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9234 around Windows filenames.
9235
9236 @example
9237 > echo \a
9238
9239 > echo @{\a@}
9240 \a
9241 > echo "\a"
9242
9243 >
9244 @end example
9245
9246
9247 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9248
9249 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9250 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9251 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9252
9253 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9254 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9255 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9256
9257 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9258 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9259 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9260
9261 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9262
9263 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9264 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9265 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9266 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9267
9268 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9269 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9270 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9271
9272 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9273 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9274
9275 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9276 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9277 memory read caused data abort".
9278
9279 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9280 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9281 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9282 be done, feel free to add this here.
9283
9284 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9285 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9286 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9287 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9288 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9289 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9290 gracefully stops.
9291
9292 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9293 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9294 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9295
9296 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9297 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9298 bytes. Painful...
9299
9300
9301 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9302 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9303
9304 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9305 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9306 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9307 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9308 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9309 reset, everything else should work fine.
9310
9311 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9312 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9313 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9314 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9315
9316 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9317 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9318 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9319 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9320
9321 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9322
9323 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9324 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9325 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9326
9327 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9328 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9329
9330 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9331 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9332 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9333 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9334 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9335 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9336 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9337 clock frequency?
9338
9339 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9340 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9341 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9342 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9343 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9344
9345 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9346
9347 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9348 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9349 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9350 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9351 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9352 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9353 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9354
9355 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9356
9357 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9358 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9359 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9360 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9361
9362 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9363 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9364 particular order?
9365
9366 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9367 the same order used by the hardware.
9368
9369 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9370 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9371 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9372 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9373 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9374 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9375
9376 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9377 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9378 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9379 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9380
9381 @itemize @bullet
9382 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9383 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9384 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9385 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9386 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9387 @end itemize
9388
9389 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9390
9391 @itemize @bullet
9392 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9393 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9394 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9395 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9396 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9397 @end itemize
9398
9399
9400 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9401 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9402 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9403
9404 TODO.
9405
9406 @end enumerate
9407
9408 @node Tcl Crash Course
9409 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9410 @cindex Tcl
9411
9412 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9413 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9414 how the Tcl scripts work.
9415
9416 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9417 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9418 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9419 OpenOCD.
9420
9421 @section Tcl Rule #1
9422 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9423 @enumerate
9424 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9425 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9426 @end enumerate
9427
9428 The Tcl equal is this:
9429
9430 @enumerate
9431 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9432 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9433 @end enumerate
9434
9435 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9436 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9437
9438 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9439 There is a second pair of rules.
9440 @enumerate
9441 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9442 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9443 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9444 in Tcl.
9445 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9446 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9447 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9448 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9449 @end enumerate
9450
9451 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9452 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9453 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9454 Everything is a string}
9455
9456 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9457 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9458 difference is subtle.
9459 @enumerate
9460 @item Parse Time
9461 @item Evaluation Time
9462 @end enumerate
9463
9464 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9465 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9466 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9467
9468 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9469 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9470 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9471 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9472
9473 @itemize @bullet
9474 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9475 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9476 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9477 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9478 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9479 @example
9480 # bash example
9481 X=`date`
9482 echo "The Date is: $X"
9483 # Tcl example
9484 set X [date]
9485 puts "The Date is: $X"
9486 @end example
9487 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9488 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9489 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9490 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9491 is a string}
9492 @example
9493 set x "Dinner"
9494 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9495 @end example
9496 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9497 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9498 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9499 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9500 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9501 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9502 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9503 @end itemize
9504
9505 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9506
9507 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9508
9509 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9510
9511 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9512 the normal way.
9513
9514 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9515 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9516 line is immedatly executed.
9517
9518 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9519 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9520
9521 @subsection Command Execution
9522
9523 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9524 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9525 control flow operators.
9526
9527 Commands are executed like this:
9528
9529 @enumerate
9530 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9531 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9532 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9533 @end enumerate
9534
9535 It sort of works like this:
9536 @example
9537 for(;;)@{
9538 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9539
9540 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9541
9542 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9543 @}
9544 @end example
9545
9546 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9547 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9548 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9549 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9550 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9551 ``LookupCommand()''
9552
9553 @subsection The FOR command
9554
9555 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9556 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9557 command just like any other command.
9558
9559 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9560 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9561 are:
9562
9563 @enumerate 0
9564 @item The ascii text 'for'
9565 @item The start text
9566 @item The test expression
9567 @item The next text
9568 @item The body text
9569 @end enumerate
9570
9571 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9572 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9573 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9574 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9575
9576 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9577 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9578
9579 @example
9580 int
9581 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9582 int *argc,
9583 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9584 @end example
9585
9586 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9587 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9588 still operates in the same basic way.
9589
9590 @subsection FOR command implementation
9591
9592 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9593 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9594
9595 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9596
9597 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9598
9599 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9600 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9601 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9602
9603 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9604 expression and returns a value.
9605
9606 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9607 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9608 @example
9609 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9610
9611 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9612
9613 int
9614 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9615 int argc,
9616 char **argv )
9617 @{
9618 if( argc != 5 )@{
9619 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9620 return ERROR;
9621 @}
9622
9623 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9624
9625 // Execute the start statement.
9626 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9627
9628 // Top of loop test
9629 for(;;)@{
9630 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9631 if( i == 0 )
9632 break;
9633
9634 // Execute the body
9635 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9636
9637 // Execute the LOOP part
9638 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9639 @}
9640
9641 // Return no error
9642 SetResult( interp, "" );
9643 return SUCCESS;
9644 @}
9645 @end example
9646
9647 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9648 in the same basic way.
9649
9650 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9651
9652 @subsection source and find commands
9653 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9654 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9655 @*Remember the parsing rules
9656 @enumerate
9657 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9658 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9659 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9660 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9661 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9662 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9663 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9664 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9665 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9666 @end enumerate
9667 @subsection format command
9668 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9669 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9670 @b{sprintf()}.
9671 @b{Example}
9672 @example
9673 set x 6
9674 set y 7
9675 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9676 @end example
9677 @enumerate
9678 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9679 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9680 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9681 @* Refer to Rule #1
9682 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9683 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9684 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9685 @end enumerate
9686 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9687 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9688 @example
9689 #1 Good
9690 proc someproc @{@} @{
9691 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9692 @}
9693 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9694 #2 Good - no variables
9695 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9696 #3 Good Curly Braces
9697 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9698 puts "Time: [date]"
9699 @}
9700 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9701 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9702 @end example
9703 @enumerate
9704 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9705 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9706 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9707 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9708 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9709 command.
9710 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9711 @*There are 4 examples:
9712 @enumerate
9713 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9714 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9715 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9716 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9717 @end enumerate
9718
9719 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9720 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9721 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9722
9723 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9724 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9725 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9726 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9727 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9728 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9729 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9730 @end enumerate
9731 @subsection Global Variables
9732 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9733 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9734 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9735 @example
9736 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9737 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9738 global x #Global variable X
9739 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9740 @}
9741 @end example
9742 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9743 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9744 @example
9745 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9746 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9747 # Create var name
9748 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9749 # Make it a global
9750 global $vn
9751 # Set it.
9752 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9753 @}
9754 @end example
9755 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9756 @example
9757 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9758 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9759 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9760 @}
9761 @end example
9762
9763 @include fdl.texi
9764
9765 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9766 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9767 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9768 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9769 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9770 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9771
9772 @printindex cp
9773
9774 @node Command and Driver Index
9775 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9776 @printindex fn
9777
9778 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)